xref: /openbmc/linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 5ae75a1a)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2022 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
22 #include <net/codel.h>
23 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
24 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
25 
26 /**
27  * DOC: Introduction
28  *
29  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
30  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
31  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
32  * drivers.
33  */
34 
35 /**
36  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
37  *
38  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
39  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
40  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
41  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
42  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
43  * tasklet function.
44  *
45  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
46  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
47  */
48 
49 /**
50  * DOC: Warning
51  *
52  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
53  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
54  */
55 
56 /**
57  * DOC: Frame format
58  *
59  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
60  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
61  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
62  * hardware.
63  *
64  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
65  *
66  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
67  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
68  *
69  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
70  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
71  */
72 
73 /**
74  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
75  *
76  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
77  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
78  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
79  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
80  *
81  * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
82  * suspend.
83  *
84  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
85  *
86  */
87 
88 /**
89  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
90  *
91  * mac80211 provides an optional intermediate queueing implementation designed
92  * to allow the driver to keep hardware queues short and provide some fairness
93  * between different stations/interfaces.
94  * In this model, the driver pulls data frames from the mac80211 queue instead
95  * of letting mac80211 push them via drv_tx().
96  * Other frames (e.g. control or management) are still pushed using drv_tx().
97  *
98  * Drivers indicate that they use this model by implementing the .wake_tx_queue
99  * driver operation.
100  *
101  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
102  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
103  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
104  *
105  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
106  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
107  *
108  * The driver can't access the queue directly. To dequeue a frame from a
109  * txq, it calls ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a
110  * queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue driver op.
111  *
112  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
113  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
114  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
115  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
116  * ieee80211_return_txq().
117  *
118  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
119  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
120  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
121  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
122  * .release_buffered_frames().
123  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
124  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
125  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
126  */
127 
128 /**
129  * DOC: HW timestamping
130  *
131  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
132  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
133  *
134  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
135  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
136  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
137  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
138  *
139  * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
140  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
141  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
142  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
143  */
144 struct device;
145 
146 /**
147  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
148  *
149  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
150  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
151  */
152 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
153 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
154 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
155 };
156 
157 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
158 
159 /**
160  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
161  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
162  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
165  */
166 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
167 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
168 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
169 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
171 };
172 
173 /**
174  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
175  *
176  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
177  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
178  *
179  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
180  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
181  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
182  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
183  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
184  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
185  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
186  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
187  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
188  */
189 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
190 	u16 txop;
191 	u16 cw_min;
192 	u16 cw_max;
193 	u8 aifs;
194 	bool acm;
195 	bool uapsd;
196 	bool mu_edca;
197 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
198 };
199 
200 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
201 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
202 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
203 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
205 };
206 
207 /**
208  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
209  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
210  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
213  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
215  */
216 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
217 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
218 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
219 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
220 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
221 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
222 };
223 
224 /**
225  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
226  *
227  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
228  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
229  *
230  * @def: the channel definition
231  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
232  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
233  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
234  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
235  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
236  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
237  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
238  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
239  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
240  */
241 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
242 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
243 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
244 
245 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
246 
247 	bool radar_enabled;
248 
249 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
250 };
251 
252 /**
253  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
254  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
255  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
256  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
257  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
258  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
259  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
260  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
261  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
262  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
263  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
264  *      for changes/removal.)
265  */
266 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
267 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
268 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
269 };
270 
271 /**
272  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
273  *
274  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
275  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
276  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
277  * done.
278  *
279  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
280  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
281  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
282  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
283  */
284 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
285 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
286 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
287 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
288 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
289 };
290 
291 /**
292  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
293  *
294  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
295  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
296  *
297  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
298  *	also implies a change in the AID.
299  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
300  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
301  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
302  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
303  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
304  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
305  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
306  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
307  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
308  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
309  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
310  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
311  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
312  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
313  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
314  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
315  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
316  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
317  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
318  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
319  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
320  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
322  *	changed
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
324  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
326  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
327  *	context had been assigned.
328  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
329  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
330  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
331  *	keep alive) changed.
332  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
333  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
334  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
336  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
339  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
340  *	status changed.
341  *
342  */
343 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
344 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
345 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
346 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
347 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
348 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
349 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
350 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
351 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
352 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
353 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
354 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
355 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
356 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
357 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
358 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
359 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
360 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
361 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
362 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
363 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
364 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
365 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
366 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
367 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
368 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
369 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
370 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
376 
377 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
378 };
379 
380 /*
381  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
382  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
383  * filtering will be disabled.
384  */
385 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
386 
387 /**
388  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
389  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
390  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
391  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
392  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
393  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
394  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
395  */
396 enum ieee80211_event_type {
397 	RSSI_EVENT,
398 	MLME_EVENT,
399 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
400 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
401 };
402 
403 /**
404  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
405  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
406  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
407  */
408 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
409 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
410 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
411 };
412 
413 /**
414  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
415  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
416  */
417 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
418 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
419 };
420 
421 /**
422  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
423  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
424  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
425  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
426  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
427  */
428 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
429 	AUTH_EVENT,
430 	ASSOC_EVENT,
431 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
432 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
433 };
434 
435 /**
436  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
437  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
438  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
439  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
440  */
441 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
442 	MLME_SUCCESS,
443 	MLME_DENIED,
444 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
445 };
446 
447 /**
448  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
449  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
450  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
451  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
452  */
453 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
454 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
455 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
456 	u16 reason;
457 };
458 
459 /**
460  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
461  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
462  * @tid: the tid
463  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
464  */
465 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
466 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
467 	u16 tid;
468 	u16 ssn;
469 };
470 
471 /**
472  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
473  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
474  * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
475  * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
476  * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
477  * @u:union holding the fields above
478  */
479 struct ieee80211_event {
480 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
481 	union {
482 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
483 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
484 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
485 	} u;
486 };
487 
488 /**
489  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
490  *
491  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
492  *
493  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
494  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
495  */
496 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
497 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
498 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
499 };
500 
501 /**
502  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
503  *
504  * @lci: LCI subelement content
505  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
506  * @lci_len: LCI data length
507  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
508  */
509 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
510 	const u8 *lci;
511 	const u8 *civicloc;
512 	size_t lci_len;
513 	size_t civicloc_len;
514 };
515 
516 /**
517  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
518  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
519  *
520  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
521  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
522  */
523 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
524 	u32 min_interval;
525 	u32 max_interval;
526 };
527 
528 /**
529  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
530  *
531  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
532  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
533  *
534  * @addr: (link) address used locally
535  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
536  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
537  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
538  * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
539  *	ACK, BACK or both
540  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
541  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
542  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
543  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
544  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
545  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
546  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
547  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
548  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
549  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
550  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
551  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
552  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
553  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
554  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
555  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
556  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
557  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
558  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
559  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
560  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
561  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
562  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
563  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
564  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
565  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
566  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
567  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
568  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
569  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
570  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
571  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
572  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
573  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
574  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
575  *	the current band.
576  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
577  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
578  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
579  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
580  * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
581  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
582  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
583  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
584  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
585  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
586  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
587  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
588  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
589  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
590  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
591  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
592  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
593  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
594  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
595  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
596  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
597  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
598  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
599  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
600  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
601  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
602  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
603  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
604  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
605  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
606  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
607  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
608  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
609  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
610  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
611  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
612  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
613  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
614  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
615  *	station.
616  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
617  *	responder functionality.
618  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
619  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
620  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
621  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
622  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
623  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
624  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
625  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
626  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
627  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
628  *	connected to (STA)
629  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
630  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
631  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
632  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
633  *	interval.
634  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
635  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
636  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
637  * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
638  * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
639  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
640  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
641  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
642  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
643  *	for read access.
644  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
645  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
646  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
647  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
648  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
649  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
650  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
651  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
652  *	for read access.
653  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
654  */
655 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
656 	const u8 *bssid;
657 	unsigned int link_id;
658 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
659 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
660 	bool uora_exists;
661 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
662 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
663 	bool he_support;
664 	bool twt_requester;
665 	bool twt_responder;
666 	bool twt_protected;
667 	bool twt_broadcast;
668 	/* erp related data */
669 	bool use_cts_prot;
670 	bool use_short_preamble;
671 	bool use_short_slot;
672 	bool enable_beacon;
673 	u8 dtim_period;
674 	u16 beacon_int;
675 	u16 assoc_capability;
676 	u64 sync_tsf;
677 	u32 sync_device_ts;
678 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
679 	u32 basic_rates;
680 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
681 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
682 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
683 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
684 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
685 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
686 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
687 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
688 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
689 	bool qos;
690 	bool hidden_ssid;
691 	int txpower;
692 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
693 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
694 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
695 	u16 max_idle_period;
696 	bool protected_keep_alive;
697 	bool ftm_responder;
698 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
699 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
700 	bool nontransmitted;
701 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
702 	u8 bssid_index;
703 	u8 bssid_indicator;
704 	bool ema_ap;
705 	u8 profile_periodicity;
706 	struct {
707 		u32 params;
708 		u16 nss_set;
709 	} he_oper;
710 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
711 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
712 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
713 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
714 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
715 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
716 	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
717 	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
718 	u8 pwr_reduction;
719 	bool eht_support;
720 
721 	bool csa_active;
722 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
723 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
724 
725 	bool color_change_active;
726 	u8 color_change_color;
727 };
728 
729 /**
730  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
731  *
732  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
733  *
734  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
735  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
736  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
737  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
738  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
739  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
740  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
741  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
742  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
743  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
744  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
745  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
746  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
747  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
748  *	station
749  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
750  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
751  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
752  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
753  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
754  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
755  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
756  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
757  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
758  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
759  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
760  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
761  *	hardware queue.
762  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
763  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
764  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
765  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
766  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
767  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
768  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
769  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
770  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
771  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
772  *	off-channel operation.
773  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
774  *	(header conversion)
775  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
776  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
777  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
778  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
779  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
780  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
781  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
782  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
783  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
784  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
785  *	queue gets full.
786  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
787  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
788  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
789  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
790  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
791  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
792  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
793  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
794  *	status to user space)
795  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
796  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
797  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
798  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
799  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
800  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
801  *	handled properly by the device.
802  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
803  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
804  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
805  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
806  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
807  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
808  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
809  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
810  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
811  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
812  *	PS-Poll responses.
813  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
814  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
815  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
816  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
817  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
818  *	monitor injection).
819  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
820  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
821  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
822  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
823  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
824  *
825  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
826  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
827  */
828 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
829 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
830 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
831 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
832 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
833 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
834 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
835 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
836 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
837 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
838 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
839 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
840 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
841 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
842 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
843 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
844 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
845 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
846 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
847 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
848 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
849 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
850 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
851 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
852 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
853 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
854 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
855 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
856 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
857 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
858 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
859 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
860 };
861 
862 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
863 
864 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
865 
866 /**
867  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
868  *
869  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
870  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
871  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
872  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
873  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
874  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
875  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
876  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
877  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
878  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
879  *	it can be sent out.
880  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
881  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
882  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
883  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
884  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
885  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
886  *	for sequence number assignment
887  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
888  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
889  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
890  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
891  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
892  *	it's intended for an MLD.
893  *
894  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
895  */
896 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
897 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
898 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
899 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
900 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
901 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
902 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
903 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
904 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
905 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
906 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
907 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
908 };
909 
910 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
911 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
912 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
913 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
914 
915 /**
916  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
917  *
918  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
919  *
920  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
921  */
922 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
923 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
924 };
925 
926 /*
927  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
928  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
929  */
930 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
931 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
932 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
933 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
934 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
935 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
936 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
937 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
938 
939 /**
940  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
941  *	Rate Control algorithm.
942  *
943  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
944  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
945  *
946  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
947  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
948  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
949  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
950  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
951  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
952  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
953  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
954  *	Greenfield mode.
955  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
956  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
957  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
958  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
959  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
960  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
961  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
962  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
963  */
964 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
965 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
966 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
967 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
968 
969 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
970 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
971 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
972 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
973 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
974 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
975 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
976 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
977 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
978 };
979 
980 
981 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
982 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
983 
984 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
985 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
986 
987 /* maximum number of rate stages */
988 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
989 
990 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
991 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
992 
993 /**
994  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
995  *
996  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
997  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
998  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
999  *
1000  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1001  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1002  *
1003  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1004  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1005  *
1006  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1007  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1008  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1009  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1010  * information::
1011  *
1012  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1013  *
1014  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1015  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1016  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1017  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1018  * information should then contain::
1019  *
1020  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1021  *
1022  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1023  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1024  */
1025 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1026 	s8 idx;
1027 	u16 count:5,
1028 	    flags:11;
1029 } __packed;
1030 
1031 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1032 
1033 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1034 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1035 {
1036 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1037 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1038 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1039 }
1040 
1041 static inline u8
1042 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1043 {
1044 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1045 }
1046 
1047 static inline u8
1048 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1049 {
1050 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1051 }
1052 
1053 /**
1054  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1055  *
1056  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1057  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1058  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1059  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1060  *
1061  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1062  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1063  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1064  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1065  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1066  * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1067  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1068  * @control: union part for control data
1069  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1070  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1071  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1072  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1073  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1074  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1075  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1076  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1077  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1078  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1079  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1080  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1081  * @pad: padding
1082  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1083  * @status: union part for status data
1084  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1085  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1086  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1087  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1088  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1089  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1090  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1091  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1092  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1093  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1094  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1095  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1096  * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1097  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1098  * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1099  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1100  * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1101  */
1102 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1103 	/* common information */
1104 	u32 flags;
1105 	u32 band:3,
1106 	    ack_frame_id:13,
1107 	    hw_queue:4,
1108 	    tx_time_est:10;
1109 	/* 2 free bits */
1110 
1111 	union {
1112 		struct {
1113 			union {
1114 				/* rate control */
1115 				struct {
1116 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1117 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1118 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1119 					u8 use_rts:1;
1120 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1121 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1122 					u8 skip_table:1;
1123 					/* 2 bytes free */
1124 				};
1125 				/* only needed before rate control */
1126 				unsigned long jiffies;
1127 			};
1128 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1129 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1130 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1131 			u32 flags;
1132 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1133 		} control;
1134 		struct {
1135 			u64 cookie;
1136 		} ack;
1137 		struct {
1138 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1139 			s32 ack_signal;
1140 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1141 			u8 ampdu_len;
1142 			u8 antenna;
1143 			u16 tx_time;
1144 			u8 flags;
1145 			void *status_driver_data[18 / sizeof(void *)];
1146 		} status;
1147 		struct {
1148 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1149 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1150 			u8 pad[4];
1151 
1152 			void *rate_driver_data[
1153 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1154 		};
1155 		void *driver_data[
1156 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1157 	};
1158 };
1159 
1160 static inline u16
1161 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1162 {
1163 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1164 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1165 	 */
1166 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1167 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1168 }
1169 
1170 static inline u16
1171 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1172 {
1173 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1174 }
1175 
1176 /***
1177  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1178  *
1179  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1180  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1181  *
1182  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1183  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1184  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1185  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1186  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1187  */
1188 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1189 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1190 	u8 try_count;
1191 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1192 };
1193 
1194 /**
1195  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1196  *
1197  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1198  * @info: Basic tx status information
1199  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1200  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1201  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1202  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1203  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1204  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1205  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1206  */
1207 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1208 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1209 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1210 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1211 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1212 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1213 	u8 n_rates;
1214 
1215 	struct list_head *free_list;
1216 };
1217 
1218 /**
1219  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1220  *
1221  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1222  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1223  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1224  *
1225  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1226  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1227  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1228  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1229  */
1230 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1231 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1232 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1233 	const u8 *common_ies;
1234 	size_t common_ie_len;
1235 };
1236 
1237 
1238 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1239 {
1240 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1241 }
1242 
1243 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1244 {
1245 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1246 }
1247 
1248 /**
1249  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1250  *
1251  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1252  *
1253  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1254  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1255  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1256  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1257  *
1258  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1259  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1260  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1261  */
1262 static inline void
1263 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1264 {
1265 	int i;
1266 
1267 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1268 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1269 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1270 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1271 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1272 	/* clear the rate counts */
1273 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1274 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1275 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1276 }
1277 
1278 
1279 /**
1280  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1281  *
1282  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1283  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1284  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1285  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1286  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1287  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1288  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1289  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1290  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1291  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1292  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1293  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1294  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1295  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1296  *	de-duplication by itself.
1297  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1298  *	the frame.
1299  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1300  *	the frame.
1301  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1302  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1303  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1304  *	merging.
1305  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1306  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1307  *	(including FCS) was received.
1308  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1309  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1310  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1311  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1312  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1313  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1314  *	each A-MPDU
1315  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1316  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1317  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1318  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1319  *	on this subframe
1320  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1321  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1322  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1323  *	done by the hardware
1324  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1325  *	processing it in any regular way.
1326  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1327  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1328  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1329  *	monitor interfaces.
1330  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1331  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1332  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1333  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1334  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1335  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1336  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1337  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1338  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1339  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1340  *	interleaved with other frames.
1341  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1342  *	radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1343  *	the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
1344  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1345  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1346  *	the first subframe.
1347  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1348  *	be done in the hardware.
1349  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1350  *	frame
1351  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1352  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1353  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1354  *
1355  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1356  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1357  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1358  *	 - DATA5_GI
1359  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1360  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1361  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1362  *
1363  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1364  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1365  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1366  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1367  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1368  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1369  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1370  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1371  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1372  *	hardware or driver)
1373  */
1374 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1375 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1376 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1377 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1378 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1379 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1380 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1381 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1382 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1383 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1384 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1385 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1386 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1387 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1388 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1389 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1390 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1391 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1392 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1393 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1394 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1395 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA	= BIT(20),
1396 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1397 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1398 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1399 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1400 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1401 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1402 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1403 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1404 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1405 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1406 };
1407 
1408 /**
1409  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1410  *
1411  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1412  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1413  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1414  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1415  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1416  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1417  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1418  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1419  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1420  */
1421 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1422 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1423 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1424 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1425 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1426 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1427 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1428 };
1429 
1430 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1431 
1432 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1433 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1434 	RX_ENC_HT,
1435 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1436 	RX_ENC_HE,
1437 };
1438 
1439 /**
1440  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1441  *
1442  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1443  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1444  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1445  *
1446  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1447  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1448  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1449  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1450  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1451  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1452  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1453  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1454  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1455  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1456  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1457  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1458  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1459  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1460  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1461  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1462  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1463  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1464  *	values were filled.
1465  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1466  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1467  * @antenna: antenna used
1468  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1469  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1470  * @nss: number of streams (VHT and HE only)
1471  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1472  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1473  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1474  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1475  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1476  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1477  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1478  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1479  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1480  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1481  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1482  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1483  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1484  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1485  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1486  *	@link_valid.
1487  */
1488 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1489 	u64 mactime;
1490 	union {
1491 		u64 boottime_ns;
1492 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1493 	};
1494 	u32 device_timestamp;
1495 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1496 	u32 flag;
1497 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1498 	u8 enc_flags;
1499 	u8 encoding:2, bw:3, he_ru:3;
1500 	u8 he_gi:2, he_dcm:1;
1501 	u8 rate_idx;
1502 	u8 nss;
1503 	u8 rx_flags;
1504 	u8 band;
1505 	u8 antenna;
1506 	s8 signal;
1507 	u8 chains;
1508 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1509 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1510 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1511 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1512 };
1513 
1514 static inline u32
1515 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1516 {
1517 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1518 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1519 }
1520 
1521 /**
1522  * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1523  * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1524  *	(this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1525  *	 bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1526  * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1527  *	alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1528  *	description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1529  *	Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1530  * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1531  * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1532  * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1533  *	then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1534  *	@data field.
1535  * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1536  *	the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1537  *	length
1538  * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1539  *
1540  * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1541  * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1542  * data.
1543  */
1544 struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1545 	u32 present;
1546 	u8 align;
1547 	u8 oui[3];
1548 	u8 subns;
1549 	u8 pad;
1550 	u16 len;
1551 	u8 data[];
1552 } __packed;
1553 
1554 /**
1555  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1556  *
1557  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1558  *
1559  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1560  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1561  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1562  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1563  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1564  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1565  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1566  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1567  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1568  *	for more.
1569  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1570  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1571  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1572  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1573  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1574  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1575  *	operating channel.
1576  */
1577 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1578 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1579 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1580 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1581 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1582 };
1583 
1584 
1585 /**
1586  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1587  *
1588  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1589  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1590  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1591  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1592  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1593  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1594  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1595  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1596  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1597  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1598  */
1599 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1600 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1601 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1602 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1603 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1604 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1605 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1606 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1607 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1608 };
1609 
1610 /**
1611  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1612  *
1613  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1614  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1615  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1616  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1617  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1618  */
1619 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1620 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1621 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1622 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1623 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1624 
1625 	/* keep last */
1626 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1627 };
1628 
1629 /**
1630  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1631  *
1632  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1633  *
1634  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1635  *
1636  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1637  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1638  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1639  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1640  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1641  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1642  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1643  *
1644  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1645  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1646  *
1647  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1648  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1649  *
1650  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1651  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1652  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1653  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1654  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1655  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1656  *
1657  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1658  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1659  *	configured for an HT channel.
1660  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1661  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1662  */
1663 struct ieee80211_conf {
1664 	u32 flags;
1665 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1666 
1667 	u16 listen_interval;
1668 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1669 
1670 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1671 
1672 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1673 	bool radar_enabled;
1674 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1675 };
1676 
1677 /**
1678  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1679  *
1680  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1681  * operation.
1682  *
1683  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1684  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1685  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1686  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1687  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1688  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1689  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1690  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1691  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1692  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1693  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1694   *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1695   *	channel, expressed in TU.
1696  */
1697 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1698 	u64 timestamp;
1699 	u32 device_timestamp;
1700 	bool block_tx;
1701 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1702 	u8 count;
1703 	u32 delay;
1704 };
1705 
1706 /**
1707  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1708  *
1709  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1710  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1711  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1712  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1713  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1714  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1715  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1716  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1717  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1718  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1719  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1720  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1721  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1722  */
1723 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1724 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1725 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1726 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1727 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1728 };
1729 
1730 
1731 /**
1732  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1733  *
1734  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1735  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1736  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1737  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1738  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1739  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1740  *	mac80211.
1741  */
1742 
1743 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1744 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1745 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1746 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1747 };
1748 
1749 /**
1750  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1751  * @assoc: association status
1752  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1753  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1754  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1755  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1756  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1757  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1758  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1759  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1760  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1761  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1762  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1763  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1764  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1765  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1766  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1767  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1768  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1769  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1770  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1771  *	(station mode only)
1772  */
1773 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1774 	/* association related data */
1775 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1776 	bool ibss_creator;
1777 	bool ps;
1778 	u16 aid;
1779 
1780 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1781 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1782 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1783 	size_t ssid_len;
1784 	bool s1g;
1785 	bool idle;
1786 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1787 };
1788 
1789 /**
1790  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1791  *
1792  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1793  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1794  *
1795  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1796  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1797  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1798  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1799  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1800  *	indexed by link ID
1801  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1802  * @addr: address of this interface
1803  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1804  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1805  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1806  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1807  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1808  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1809  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1810  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1811  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1812  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1813  *	restrictions.
1814  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1815  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1816  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1817  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1818  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1819  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1820  *	interface.
1821  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1822  *	for this interface.
1823  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1824  *	sizeof(void \*).
1825  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction)
1826  * @txqs_stopped: per AC flag to indicate that intermediate TXQs are stopped,
1827  *	protected by fq->lock.
1828  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1829  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1830  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1831  */
1832 struct ieee80211_vif {
1833 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1834 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1835 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1836 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1837 	u16 valid_links;
1838 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1839 	bool p2p;
1840 
1841 	u8 cab_queue;
1842 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1843 
1844 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1845 
1846 	u32 driver_flags;
1847 	u32 offload_flags;
1848 
1849 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1850 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1851 #endif
1852 
1853 	bool probe_req_reg;
1854 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1855 
1856 	bool txqs_stopped[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1857 
1858 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1859 
1860 	/* must be last */
1861 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1862 };
1863 
1864 /* FIXME: for now loop over all the available links; later will be changed
1865  * to loop only over the active links.
1866  */
1867 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)			     \
1868 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
1869 		if ((link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1870 
1871 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1872 {
1873 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1874 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1875 #endif
1876 	return false;
1877 }
1878 
1879 /**
1880  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1881  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1882  *
1883  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1884  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1885  *
1886  * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1887  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1888  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1889  */
1890 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1891 
1892 /**
1893  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1894  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1895  *
1896  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1897  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1898  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1899  */
1900 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1901 
1902 /**
1903  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1904  *
1905  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1906  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1907  *
1908  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1909  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1910  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1911  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1912  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1913  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1914  *	generation in software.
1915  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1916  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1917  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1918  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1919  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1920  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1921  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1922  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1923  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1924  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1925  *	MIC.
1926  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1927  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1928  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1929  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1930  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1931  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1932  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1933  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1934  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1935  *	only for management frames (MFP).
1936  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1937  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1938  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
1939  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
1940  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
1941  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
1942  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
1943  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
1944  *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
1945  *	generation only
1946  */
1947 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
1948 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
1949 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
1950 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
1951 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
1952 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
1953 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
1954 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
1955 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
1956 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
1957 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
1958 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
1959 };
1960 
1961 /**
1962  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
1963  *
1964  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
1965  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
1966  *
1967  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
1968  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
1969  *	encrypted in hardware.
1970  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
1971  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
1972  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
1973  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
1974  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
1975  * @keylen: key material length
1976  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
1977  * 	data block:
1978  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
1979  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
1980  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
1981  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
1982  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
1983  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
1984  */
1985 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
1986 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
1987 	u32 cipher;
1988 	u8 icv_len;
1989 	u8 iv_len;
1990 	u8 hw_key_idx;
1991 	s8 keyidx;
1992 	u16 flags;
1993 	s8 link_id;
1994 	u8 keylen;
1995 	u8 key[];
1996 };
1997 
1998 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
1999 
2000 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2001 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2002 
2003 /**
2004  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2005  *
2006  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2007  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2008  *	reverse order than in packet)
2009  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2010  *	reverse order than in packet)
2011  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2012  *	reverse order than in packet)
2013  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2014  *	reverse order than in packet)
2015  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2016  */
2017 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2018 	union {
2019 		struct {
2020 			u32 iv32;
2021 			u16 iv16;
2022 		} tkip;
2023 		struct {
2024 			u8 pn[6];
2025 		} ccmp;
2026 		struct {
2027 			u8 pn[6];
2028 		} aes_cmac;
2029 		struct {
2030 			u8 pn[6];
2031 		} aes_gmac;
2032 		struct {
2033 			u8 pn[6];
2034 		} gcmp;
2035 		struct {
2036 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2037 			u8 seq_len;
2038 		} hw;
2039 	};
2040 };
2041 
2042 /**
2043  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2044  *
2045  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2046  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2047  *
2048  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2049  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2050  */
2051 enum set_key_cmd {
2052 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2053 };
2054 
2055 /**
2056  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2057  *
2058  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2059  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2060  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2061  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2062  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2063  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2064  */
2065 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2066 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2067 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2068 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2069 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2070 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2071 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2072 };
2073 
2074 /**
2075  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2076  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2077  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2078  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2079  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2080  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2081  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2082  *
2083  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2084  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2085  */
2086 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2087 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2088 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2089 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2090 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2091 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2092 };
2093 
2094 /**
2095  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2096  *
2097  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2098  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2099  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2100  */
2101 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2102 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2103 	struct {
2104 		s8 idx;
2105 		u8 count;
2106 		u8 count_cts;
2107 		u8 count_rts;
2108 		u16 flags;
2109 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2110 };
2111 
2112 /**
2113  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2114  *
2115  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2116  *
2117  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2118  *	to the STA.
2119  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2120  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2121  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2122  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2123  *	per peer TPC.
2124  */
2125 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2126 	s16 power;
2127 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2128 };
2129 
2130 /**
2131  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2132  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2133  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2134  *
2135  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2136  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2137  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2138  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2139  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2140  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2141  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2142  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2143  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2144  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2145  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2146  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2147  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2148  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2149  *	the station moves to associated state.
2150  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2151  *
2152  */
2153 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2154 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2155 	u8 link_id;
2156 
2157 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2158 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2159 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2160 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2161 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2162 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2163 
2164 	u8 rx_nss;
2165 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2166 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2167 };
2168 
2169 /**
2170  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2171  *
2172  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2173  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2174  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2175  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2176  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2177  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2178  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2179  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2180  *
2181  * @addr: MAC address
2182  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2183  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2184  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2185  *	Can be modified by driver.
2186  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2187  *	otherwise always false)
2188  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2189  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2190  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2191  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2192  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2193  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2194  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2195  * @rates: rate control selection table
2196  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2197  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2198  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2199  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2200  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2201  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2202  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2203  *	unlimited.
2204  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2205  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2206  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2207  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction); note that
2208  *	the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) is used for non-data frames
2209  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2210  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2211  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2212  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2213  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2214  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2215  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2216  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2217  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2218  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2219  *	by the AP.
2220  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2221  */
2222 struct ieee80211_sta {
2223 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2224 	u16 aid;
2225 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2226 	bool wme;
2227 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2228 	u8 max_sp;
2229 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2230 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2231 	bool tdls;
2232 	bool tdls_initiator;
2233 	bool mfp;
2234 	bool mlo;
2235 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2236 
2237 	/**
2238 	 * @max_amsdu_len:
2239 	 * indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2240 	 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2241 	 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2242 	 *
2243 	 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2244 	 *   A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2245 	 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2246 	 *   size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2247 	 *
2248 	 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2249 	 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2250 	 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2251 	 */
2252 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2253 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2254 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2255 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2256 
2257 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2258 
2259 	u16 valid_links;
2260 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2261 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2262 
2263 	/* must be last */
2264 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2265 };
2266 
2267 /* FIXME: need to loop only over links which are active and check the actual
2268  * lock
2269  */
2270 #define for_each_sta_active_link(sta, link_sta, link_id)		         \
2271 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)	         \
2272 		if (((link_sta) = rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],\
2273 							    1)))	         \
2274 
2275 /**
2276  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2277  *
2278  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2279  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2280  *
2281  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2282  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2283  */
2284 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2285 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2286 };
2287 
2288 /**
2289  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2290  *
2291  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2292  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2293  */
2294 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2295 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2296 };
2297 
2298 /**
2299  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2300  *
2301  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2302  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2303  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2304  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2305  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2306  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2307  *
2308  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2309  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2310  */
2311 struct ieee80211_txq {
2312 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2313 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2314 	u8 tid;
2315 	u8 ac;
2316 
2317 	/* must be last */
2318 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2319 };
2320 
2321 /**
2322  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2323  *
2324  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2325  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2326  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2327  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2328  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2329  *
2330  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2331  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2332  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2333  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2334  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2335  *	algorithm.
2336  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2337  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2338  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2339  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2340  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2341  *	CCK frames.
2342  *
2343  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2344  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2345  *	the FCS at the end.
2346  *
2347  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2348  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2349  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2350  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2351  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2352  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2353  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2354  *
2355  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2356  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2357  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2358  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2359  *
2360  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2361  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2362  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2363  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2364  *
2365  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2366  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2367  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2368  *
2369  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2370  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2371  *
2372  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2373  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2374  *
2375  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2376  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2377  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2378  *
2379  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2380  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2381  *
2382  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2383  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2384  *
2385  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2386  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2387  *	the stack.
2388  *
2389  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2390  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2391  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2392  *
2393  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2394  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2395  *	dtim_period).
2396  *
2397  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2398  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2399  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2400  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2401  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2402  *	only in that case.
2403  *
2404  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2405  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2406  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2407  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2408  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2409  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2410  *
2411  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2412  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2413  *	software.
2414  *
2415  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2416  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2417  *	active interfaces.
2418  *
2419  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2420  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2421  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2422  *
2423  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2424  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2425  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2426  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2427  *	supported cipher suites.
2428  *
2429  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2430  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2431  *	for frames.
2432  *
2433  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2434  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2435  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2436  *	control for more details.
2437  *
2438  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2439  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2440  *
2441  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2442  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2443  *	is supported.
2444  *
2445  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2446  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2447  *
2448  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2449  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2450  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2451  *
2452  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2453  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2454  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2455  *	CSA frame.
2456  *
2457  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2458  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2459  *
2460  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2461  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2462  *
2463  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2464  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2465  *
2466  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2467  *	within A-MPDU.
2468  *
2469  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2470  *	for sent beacons.
2471  *
2472  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2473  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2474  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2475  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2476  *
2477  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2478  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2479  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2480  *	timeout.
2481  *
2482  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2483  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2484  *
2485  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2486  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2487  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2488  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2489  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2490  *
2491  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2492  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2493  *
2494  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2495  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2496  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2497  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2498  *
2499  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2500  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2501  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2502  *
2503  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2504  *	TDLS links.
2505  *
2506  * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2507  *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2508  *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2509  *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2510  *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2511  *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2512  *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2513  *
2514  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2515  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2516  *
2517  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2518  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2519  *
2520  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2521  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2522  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2523  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2524  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2525  *
2526  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2527  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2528  *	TXQs to start with.
2529  *
2530  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2531  *	length in tx status information
2532  *
2533  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2534  *
2535  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2536  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2537  *
2538  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2539  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2540  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2541  *
2542  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2543  *	offload
2544  *
2545  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2546  *	offload
2547  *
2548  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2549  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2550  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2551  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2552  *	the stack.
2553  *
2554  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2555  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2556  *
2557  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2558  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2559  *
2560  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2561  */
2562 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2563 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2564 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2565 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2566 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2567 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2568 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2569 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2570 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2571 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2572 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2573 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2574 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2575 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2576 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2577 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2578 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2579 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2580 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2581 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2582 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2583 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2584 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2585 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2586 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2587 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2588 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2589 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2590 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2591 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2592 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2593 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2594 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2595 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2596 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2597 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2598 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2599 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2600 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2601 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2602 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2603 	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2604 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2605 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2606 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2607 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2608 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2609 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2610 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2611 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2612 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2613 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2614 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2615 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2616 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2617 
2618 	/* keep last, obviously */
2619 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2620 };
2621 
2622 /**
2623  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2624  *
2625  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2626  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2627  *
2628  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2629  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2630  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2631  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2632  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2633  *
2634  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2635  *
2636  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2637  *	along with this structure.
2638  *
2639  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2640  *
2641  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2642  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2643  *
2644  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2645  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2646  *
2647  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2648  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2649  *
2650  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2651  *	that HW supports
2652  *
2653  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2654  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2655  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2656  *
2657  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2658  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2659  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2660  *
2661  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2662  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2663  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2664  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2665  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2666  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2667  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2668  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2669  *
2670  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2671  *	can handle.
2672  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2673  *	the hw can report back.
2674  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2675  *
2676  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2677  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2678  *	aggregation.
2679  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2680  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2681  *	it shouldn't be set.
2682  *
2683  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2684  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2685  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2686  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2687  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2688  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2689  *
2690  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2691  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2692  *
2693  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2694  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2695  *
2696  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2697  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2698  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2699  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2700  *
2701  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2702  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2703  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2704  *
2705  * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2706  *
2707  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2708  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2709  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2710  *	device_timestamp.
2711  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2712  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2713  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2714  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2715  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2716  *
2717  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2718  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2719  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2720  *
2721  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2722  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2723  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2724  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2725  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2726  *	neither enabled.
2727  *
2728  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2729  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2730  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2731  *
2732  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2733  *	device.
2734  *
2735  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2736  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2737  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2738  *
2739  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2740  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2741  *
2742  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2743  *
2744  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2745  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2746  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2747  *
2748  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2749  */
2750 struct ieee80211_hw {
2751 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2752 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2753 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2754 	void *priv;
2755 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2756 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2757 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2758 	int vif_data_size;
2759 	int sta_data_size;
2760 	int chanctx_data_size;
2761 	int txq_data_size;
2762 	u16 queues;
2763 	u16 max_listen_interval;
2764 	s8 max_signal;
2765 	u8 max_rates;
2766 	u8 max_report_rates;
2767 	u8 max_rate_tries;
2768 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2769 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2770 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2771 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2772 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2773 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2774 	struct {
2775 		int units_pos;
2776 		s16 accuracy;
2777 	} radiotap_timestamp;
2778 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2779 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2780 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2781 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2782 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2783 	u8 weight_multiplier;
2784 	u32 max_mtu;
2785 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2786 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2787 };
2788 
2789 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2790 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2791 {
2792 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2793 }
2794 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2795 
2796 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2797 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2798 {
2799 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2800 }
2801 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2802 
2803 /**
2804  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2805  *
2806  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2807  * @req: cfg80211 request.
2808  */
2809 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2810 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2811 
2812 	/* Keep last */
2813 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2814 };
2815 
2816 /**
2817  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2818  *
2819  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2820  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2821  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2822  * @status: channel-switch response status
2823  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2824  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2825  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2826  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2827  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2828  */
2829 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2830 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2831 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2832 	u8 action_code;
2833 	u32 status;
2834 	u32 timestamp;
2835 	u16 switch_time;
2836 	u16 switch_timeout;
2837 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2838 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2839 };
2840 
2841 /**
2842  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2843  *
2844  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2845  *
2846  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2847  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2848  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2849  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2850  * is already used internally by mac80211.
2851  *
2852  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2853  */
2854 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2855 
2856 /**
2857  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2858  *
2859  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2860  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2861  */
2862 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2863 {
2864 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2865 }
2866 
2867 /**
2868  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2869  *
2870  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2871  * @addr: the address to set
2872  */
2873 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2874 {
2875 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2876 }
2877 
2878 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2879 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2880 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2881 {
2882 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2883 		return NULL;
2884 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2885 }
2886 
2887 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2888 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2889 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2890 {
2891 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2892 		return NULL;
2893 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2894 }
2895 
2896 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2897 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2898 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2899 {
2900 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2901 		return NULL;
2902 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2903 }
2904 
2905 /**
2906  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
2907  * @hw: the hardware
2908  * @skb: the skb
2909  *
2910  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
2911  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
2912  */
2913 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2914 
2915 /**
2916  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
2917  *
2918  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
2919  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
2920  *
2921  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
2922  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
2923  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
2924  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
2925  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
2926  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
2927  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
2928  *
2929  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
2930  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
2931  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
2932  *
2933  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
2934  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
2935  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
2936  * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
2937  *
2938  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
2939  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
2940  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
2941  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
2942  *
2943  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
2944  *
2945  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
2946  * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
2947  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
2948  * based on the receive flags.
2949  *
2950  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
2951  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
2952  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
2953  * keys.
2954  *
2955  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
2956  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
2957  * handler.
2958  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
2959  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
2960  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
2961  * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
2962  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
2963  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
2964  *
2965  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
2966  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
2967  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
2968  *
2969  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
2970  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
2971  * requirements:
2972  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
2973       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
2974    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
2975       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
2976    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
2977       encrypted with the new key when also needing
2978       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
2979    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
2980    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
2981  */
2982 
2983 /**
2984  * DOC: Powersave support
2985  *
2986  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
2987  *
2988  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
2989  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
2990  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
2991  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
2992  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
2993  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
2994  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
2995  * it finds traffic directed to it.
2996  *
2997  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
2998  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
2999  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3000  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3001  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3002  *
3003  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3004  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3005  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3006  *
3007  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3008  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3009  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3010  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3011  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3012  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3013  * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3014  *
3015  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3016  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3017  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3018  * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3019  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3020  * periods.
3021  *
3022  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3023  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3024  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3025  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3026  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3027  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3028  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3029  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3030  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3031  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3032  *
3033  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3034  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3035  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3036  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3037  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3038  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3039  *
3040  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3041  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3042  */
3043 
3044 /**
3045  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3046  *
3047  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3048  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3049  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3050  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3051  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3052  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3053  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3054  *
3055  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3056  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3057  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3058  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3059  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3060  *
3061  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3062  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3063  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3064  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3065  *
3066  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3067  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3068  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3069  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3070  *
3071  *  - a list of information element IDs
3072  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3073  *
3074  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3075  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3076  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3077  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3078  * vendor information elements.
3079  *
3080  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3081  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3082  *
3083  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3084  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3085  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3086  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3087  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3088  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3089  *
3090  *
3091  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3092  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3093  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3094  * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3095  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3096  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3097  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3098  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3099  *
3100  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3101  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3102  * signal strength threshold checking.
3103  */
3104 
3105 /**
3106  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3107  *
3108  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3109  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3110  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3111  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3112  *
3113  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3114  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3115  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3116  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3117  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3118  * hardware flags.
3119  *
3120  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3121  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3122  * turned off otherwise.
3123  *
3124  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3125  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3126  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3127  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3128  */
3129 
3130 /**
3131  * DOC: Frame filtering
3132  *
3133  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3134  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3135  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3136  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3137  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3138  *
3139  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3140  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3141  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3142  *
3143  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3144  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3145  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3146  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3147  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3148  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3149  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3150  *
3151  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3152  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3153  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3154  * or dropped.
3155  *
3156  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3157  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3158  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3159  * the flag, but not clear it.
3160  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3161  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3162  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3163  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3164  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3165  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3166  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3167  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3168  */
3169 
3170 /**
3171  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3172  *
3173  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3174  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3175  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3176  *
3177  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3178  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3179  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3180  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3181  * the driver code.
3182  *
3183  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3184  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3185  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3186  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3187  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3188  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3189  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3190  *
3191  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3192  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3193  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3194  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3195  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3196  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3197  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3198  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3199  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3200  * @sta_notify callback.
3201  *
3202  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3203  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3204  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3205  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3206  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3207  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3208  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3209  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3210  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3211  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3212  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3213  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3214  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3215  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3216  *
3217  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3218  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3219  *
3220  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3221  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3222  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3223  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3224  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3225  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3226  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3227  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3228  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3229  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3230  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3231  *
3232  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3233  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3234  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3235  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3236  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3237  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3238  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3239  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3240  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3241  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3242  * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3243  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3244  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3245  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3246  *
3247  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3248  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3249  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3250  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3251  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3252  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3253  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3254  *
3255  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3256  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3257  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3258  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3259  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3260  *
3261  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3262  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3263  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3264  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3265  */
3266 
3267 /**
3268  * DOC: HW queue control
3269  *
3270  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3271  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3272  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3273  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3274  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3275  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3276  *
3277  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3278  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3279  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3280  *
3281  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3282  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3283  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3284  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3285  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3286  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3287  * the hardware queue.
3288  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3289  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3290  *
3291  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3292  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3293  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3294  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3295  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3296  *
3297  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3298  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3299  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3300  * off-channel queue:         9
3301  *
3302  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3303  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3304  *
3305  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3306  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3307  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3308  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3309  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3310  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3311  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3312  *
3313  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3314  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3315  *
3316  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3317  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3318  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3319  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3320  */
3321 
3322 /**
3323  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3324  *
3325  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3326  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3327  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3328  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3329  *
3330  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3331  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3332  *	multicast address.
3333  *
3334  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3335  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3336  *
3337  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3338  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3339  *
3340  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3341  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3342  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3343  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3344  *	honour this flag if possible.
3345  *
3346  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3347  *	station
3348  *
3349  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3350  *
3351  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3352  *
3353  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3354  *
3355  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3356  */
3357 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3358 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3359 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3360 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3361 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3362 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3363 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3364 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3365 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3366 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3367 };
3368 
3369 /**
3370  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3371  *
3372  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3373  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3374  *
3375  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3376  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3377  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3378  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3379  *
3380  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3381  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3382  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3383  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3384  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3385  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3386  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3387  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3388  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3389  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3390  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3391  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3392  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3393  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3394  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3395  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3396  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3397  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3398  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3399  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3400  */
3401 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3402 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3403 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3404 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3405 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3406 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3407 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3408 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3409 };
3410 
3411 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3412 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3413 
3414 /**
3415  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3416  *
3417  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3418  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3419  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3420  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3421  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3422  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3423  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3424  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3425  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3426  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3427  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3428  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3429  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3430  */
3431 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3432 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3433 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3434 	u16 tid;
3435 	u16 ssn;
3436 	u16 buf_size;
3437 	bool amsdu;
3438 	u16 timeout;
3439 };
3440 
3441 /**
3442  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3443  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3444  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3445  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3446  */
3447 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3448 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3449 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3450 };
3451 
3452 /**
3453  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3454  *
3455  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3456  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3457  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3458  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3459  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3460  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3461  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3462  *	the peer.
3463  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3464  *	by the peer
3465  */
3466 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3467 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3468 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3469 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3470 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3471 };
3472 
3473 /**
3474  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3475  *
3476  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3477  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3478  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3479  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3480  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3481  *
3482  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3483  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3484  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3485  */
3486 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3487 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3488 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3489 };
3490 
3491 /**
3492  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3493  *
3494  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3495  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3496  *
3497  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3498  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3499  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3500  *	of wowlan configuration)
3501  */
3502 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3503 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3504 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3505 };
3506 
3507 /**
3508  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3509  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3510  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3511  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3512  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3513  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3514  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3515  */
3516 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3517 	u16 duration;
3518 	u16 subtype;
3519 	u8 success:1;
3520 };
3521 
3522 /**
3523  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3524  *
3525  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3526  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3527  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3528  *
3529  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3530  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3531  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3532  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3533  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3534  *	Must be atomic.
3535  *
3536  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3537  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3538  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3539  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3540  *	or zero.
3541  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3542  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3543  *	is added.
3544  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3545  *
3546  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3547  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3548  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3549  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3550  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3551  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3552  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3553  *
3554  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3555  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3556  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3557  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3558  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3559  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3560  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3561  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3562  *	must return 1 from this function.
3563  *
3564  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3565  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3566  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3567  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3568  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3569  *
3570  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3571  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3572  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3573  *	in suspend().
3574  *
3575  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3576  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3577  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3578  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3579  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3580  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3581  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3582  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3583  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3584  *
3585  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3586  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3587  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3588  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3589  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3590  *
3591  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3592  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3593  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3594  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3595  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3596  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3597  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3598  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3599  *
3600  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3601  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3602  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3603  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3604  *
3605  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3606  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3607  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3608  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3609  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3610  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3611  *	can sleep.
3612  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3613  *	are not implemented.
3614  *
3615  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3616  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3617  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3618  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3619  *	The callback can sleep.
3620  *
3621  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3622  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3623  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3624  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3625  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3626  *	non-MLO connections.
3627  *	The callback can sleep.
3628  *
3629  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3630  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3631  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3632  *
3633  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3634  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3635  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3636  *
3637  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3638  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3639  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3640  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3641  *	which flags are changed.
3642  *	This callback can sleep.
3643  *
3644  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3645  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3646  *
3647  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3648  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3649  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3650  *	is enabled.
3651  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3652  *	The callback can sleep.
3653  *
3654  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3655  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3656  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3657  *	The callback must be atomic.
3658  *
3659  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3660  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3661  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3662  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3663  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3664  *
3665  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3666  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3667  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3668  *
3669  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3670  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3671  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3672  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3673  *	that power save is disabled.
3674  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3675  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3676  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3677  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3678  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3679  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3680  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3681  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3682  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3683  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3684  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3685  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3686  *	The callback can sleep.
3687  *
3688  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3689  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3690  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3691  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3692  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3693  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3694  *	The callback can sleep.
3695  *
3696  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3697  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3698  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3699  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3700  *
3701  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3702  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3703  *
3704  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3705  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3706  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3707  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3708  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3709  *
3710  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3711  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3712  *	this notification.
3713  *	The callback can sleep.
3714  *
3715  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3716  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3717  *	The callback can sleep.
3718  *
3719  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3720  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3721  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3722  *	The callback must be atomic.
3723  *
3724  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3725  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3726  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3727  *	should be set as well.
3728  *	The callback can sleep.
3729  *
3730  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3731  *	The callback can sleep.
3732  *
3733  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3734  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3735  *
3736  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3737  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3738  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3739  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3740  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3741  *	This callback can sleep.
3742  *
3743  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3744  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3745  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3746  *	callback can sleep.
3747  *
3748  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3749  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3750  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3751  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3752  *
3753  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3754  *	power for the station.
3755  *	This callback can sleep.
3756  *
3757  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3758  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3759  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3760  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3761  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3762  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3763  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3764  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3765  *	The callback can sleep.
3766  *
3767  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3768  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3769  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3770  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3771  *	in @sta_state.
3772  *	The callback can sleep.
3773  *
3774  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3775  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3776  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3777  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3778  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3779  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3780  *	Must be atomic.
3781  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3782  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3783  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3784  *
3785  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3786  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3787  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3788  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3789  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3790  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3791  *	The callback can sleep.
3792  *
3793  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3794  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3795  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3796  *	The callback can sleep.
3797  *
3798  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3799  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3800  *	required function.
3801  *	The callback can sleep.
3802  *
3803  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3804  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3805  *	required function.
3806  *	The callback can sleep.
3807  *
3808  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3809  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3810  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3811  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3812  *	The callback can sleep.
3813  *
3814  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3815  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3816  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3817  *	TSF synchronization.
3818  *	The callback can sleep.
3819  *
3820  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3821  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3822  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3823  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3824  *	The callback can sleep.
3825  *
3826  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3827  *
3828  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3829  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3830  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3831  *	The callback can sleep.
3832  *
3833  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3834  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3835  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3836  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3837  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3838  *
3839  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3840  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3841  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3842  *
3843  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3844  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3845  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3846  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3847  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3848  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3849  *	The callback can sleep.
3850  *
3851  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3852  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3853  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3854  *	completion of the channel switch.
3855  *
3856  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3857  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3858  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3859  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3860  *
3861  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3862  *
3863  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3864  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3865  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3866  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3867  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3868  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3869  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3870  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3871  *	must be accepted in this case.
3872  *	This callback may sleep.
3873  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3874  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3875  *
3876  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3877  *
3878  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3879  *
3880  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3881  *	queues before entering power save.
3882  *
3883  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3884  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3885  *	The callback can sleep.
3886  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3887  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3888  *	The callback must be atomic.
3889  *
3890  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3891  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3892  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3893  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3894  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3895  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3896  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3897  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
3898  *	more-data bit must always be set.
3899  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
3900  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
3901  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
3902  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
3903  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3904  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
3905  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
3906  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
3907  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
3908  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
3909  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
3910  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
3911  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
3912  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
3913  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
3914  *	This callback must be atomic.
3915  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
3916  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
3917  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
3918  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
3919  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
3920  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
3921  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3922  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
3923  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
3924  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
3925  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
3926  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
3927  *	This callback must be atomic.
3928  *
3929  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
3930  *
3931  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
3932  *
3933  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
3934  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
3935  *
3936  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
3937  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
3938  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
3939  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
3940  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
3941  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
3942  *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
3943  *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
3944  *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
3945  *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
3946  *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
3947  *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
3948  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
3949  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
3950  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
3951  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
3952  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
3953  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
3954  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
3955  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
3956  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
3957  *
3958  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
3959  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
3960  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
3961  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
3962  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
3963  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
3964  *	2 * (DTIM period).
3965  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
3966  *
3967  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
3968  *	This callback may sleep.
3969  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
3970  *	This callback may sleep.
3971  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
3972  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
3973  *	channel context with different settings
3974  *	This callback may sleep.
3975  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
3976  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
3977  *	This callback may sleep.
3978  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
3979  *	unbound from vif.
3980  *	This callback may sleep.
3981  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
3982  *	another, as specified in the list of
3983  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
3984  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
3985  *	This callback may sleep.
3986  *
3987  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
3988  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
3989  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
3990  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
3991  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
3992  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
3993  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
3994  *
3995  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
3996  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
3997  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
3998  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
3999  *	This callback may sleep.
4000  *
4001  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4002  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4003  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4004  *
4005  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4006  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4007  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4008  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4009  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4010  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4011  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4012  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4013  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4014  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4015  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4016  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4017  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4018  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4019  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4020  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4021  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4022  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4023  *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4024  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4025  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4026  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4027  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4028  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4029  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4030  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4031  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4032  *
4033  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4034  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4035  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4036  *
4037  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4038  *	and hardware limits.
4039  *
4040  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4041  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4042  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4043  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4044  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4045  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4046  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4047  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4048  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4049  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4050  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4051  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4052  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4053  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4054  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4055  *	the function call.
4056  *
4057  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4058  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4059  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4060  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4061  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4062  *
4063  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4064  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4065  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4066  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4067  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4068  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4069  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4070  *	changed parameters.
4071  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4072  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4073  *	this call.
4074  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4075  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4076  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4077  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4078  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4079  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4080  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4081  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4082  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4083  *
4084  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4085  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4086  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4087  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4088  *	This callback may sleep.
4089  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4090  *	This callback may sleep.
4091  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4092  *	4-address mode
4093  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4094  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4095  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4096  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4097  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4098  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4099  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4100  *	twt structure.
4101  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4102  *	from the peer.
4103  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4104  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4105  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4106  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4107  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4108  *	radar channel.
4109  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4110  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4111  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4112  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4113  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4114  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4115  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4116  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4117  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4118  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4119  *	This callback can sleep.
4120  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4121  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4122  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4123  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4124  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4125  */
4126 struct ieee80211_ops {
4127 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4128 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4129 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4130 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4131 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4132 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4133 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4134 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4135 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4136 #endif
4137 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4138 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4139 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4140 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4141 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4142 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4143 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4144 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4145 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4146 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4147 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4148 				 u64 changed);
4149 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4150 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4151 				u64 changed);
4152 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4153 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4154 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4155 				  u64 changed);
4156 
4157 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4158 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4159 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4160 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4161 
4162 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4163 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4164 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4165 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4166 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4167 				 u64 multicast);
4168 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4169 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4170 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4171 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4172 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4173 		       bool set);
4174 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4175 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4176 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4177 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4178 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4179 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4180 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4181 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4182 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4183 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4184 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4185 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4186 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4187 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4188 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4189 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4190 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4191 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4192 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4193 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4194 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4195 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4196 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4197 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4198 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4199 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4200 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4201 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4202 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4203 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4204 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4205 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4206 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4207 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4208 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4209 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4210 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4211 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4212 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4213 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4214 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4215 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4216 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4217 				struct dentry *dir);
4218 #endif
4219 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4220 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4221 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4222 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4223 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4224 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4225 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4226 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4227 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4228 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4229 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4230 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4231 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4232 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4233 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4234 			      u32 changed);
4235 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4236 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4237 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4238 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4239 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4240 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4241 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4242 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4243 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4244 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4245 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4246 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4247 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4248 			u64 tsf);
4249 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4250 			   s64 offset);
4251 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4252 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4253 
4254 	/**
4255 	 * @ampdu_action:
4256 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4257 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4258 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4259 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4260 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4261 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4262 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4263 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4264 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4265 	 *
4266 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4267 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4268 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4269 	 *
4270 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4271 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4272 	 *
4273 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4274 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4275 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4276 	 *
4277 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4278 	 *
4279 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4280 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4281 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4282 	 *
4283 	 * The callback can sleep.
4284 	 */
4285 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4286 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4287 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4288 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4289 		struct survey_info *survey);
4290 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4291 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4292 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4293 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4294 			    void *data, int len);
4295 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4296 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4297 			     void *data, int len);
4298 #endif
4299 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4300 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4301 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4302 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4303 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4304 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4305 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4306 
4307 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4308 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4309 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4310 				 int duration,
4311 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4312 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4313 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4314 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4315 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4316 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4317 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4318 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4319 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4320 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4321 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4322 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4323 
4324 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4325 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4326 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4327 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4328 				      bool more_data);
4329 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4330 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4331 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4332 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4333 					bool more_data);
4334 
4335 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4336 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4337 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4338 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4339 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4340 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4341 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4342 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4343 
4344 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4345 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4346 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4347 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4348 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4349 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4350 
4351 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4352 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4353 
4354 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4355 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4356 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4357 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4358 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4359 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4360 			       u32 changed);
4361 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4362 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4363 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4364 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4365 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4366 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4367 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4368 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4369 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4370 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4371 				  int n_vifs,
4372 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4373 
4374 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4375 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4376 
4377 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4378 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4379 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4380 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4381 #endif
4382 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4383 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4384 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4385 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4386 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4387 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4388 
4389 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4390 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4391 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4392 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4393 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4394 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4395 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4396 
4397 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4398 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4399 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4400 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4401 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4402 			   int *dbm);
4403 
4404 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4405 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4406 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4407 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4408 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4409 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4410 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4411 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4412 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4413 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4414 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4415 
4416 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4417 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4418 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4419 
4420 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4421 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4422 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4423 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4424 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4425 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4426 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4427 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4428 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4429 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4430 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4431 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4432 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4433 			    u8 instance_id);
4434 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4435 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4436 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4437 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4438 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4439 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4440 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4441 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4442 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4443 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4444 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4445 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4446 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4447 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4448 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4449 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4450 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4451 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4452 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4453 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4454 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4455 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4456 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4457 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4458 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4459 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4460 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4461 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4462 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4463 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4464 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4465 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4466 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4467 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4468 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4469 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4470 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4471 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4472 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4473 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4474 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4475 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4476 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4477 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4478 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4479 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4480 };
4481 
4482 /**
4483  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4484  *
4485  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4486  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4487  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4488  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4489  * @priv_data_len.
4490  *
4491  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4492  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4493  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4494  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4495  *
4496  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4497  */
4498 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4499 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4500 					   const char *requested_name);
4501 
4502 /**
4503  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4504  *
4505  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4506  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4507  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4508  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4509  * @priv_data_len.
4510  *
4511  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4512  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4513  *
4514  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4515  */
4516 static inline
4517 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4518 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4519 {
4520 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4521 }
4522 
4523 /**
4524  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4525  *
4526  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4527  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4528  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4529  *
4530  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4531  *
4532  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4533  */
4534 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4535 
4536 /**
4537  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4538  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4539  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4540  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4541  */
4542 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4543 	int throughput;
4544 	int blink_time;
4545 };
4546 
4547 /**
4548  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4549  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4550  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4551  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4552  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4553  */
4554 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4555 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4556 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4557 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4558 };
4559 
4560 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4561 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4562 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4563 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4564 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4565 const char *
4566 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4567 				   unsigned int flags,
4568 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4569 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4570 #endif
4571 /**
4572  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4573  *
4574  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4575  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4576  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4577  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4578  *
4579  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4580  *
4581  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4582  */
4583 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4584 {
4585 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4586 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4587 #else
4588 	return NULL;
4589 #endif
4590 }
4591 
4592 /**
4593  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4594  *
4595  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4596  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4597  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4598  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4599  *
4600  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4601  *
4602  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4603  */
4604 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4605 {
4606 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4607 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4608 #else
4609 	return NULL;
4610 #endif
4611 }
4612 
4613 /**
4614  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4615  *
4616  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4617  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4618  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4619  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4620  *
4621  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4622  *
4623  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4624  */
4625 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4626 {
4627 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4628 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4629 #else
4630 	return NULL;
4631 #endif
4632 }
4633 
4634 /**
4635  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4636  *
4637  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4638  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4639  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4640  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4641  *
4642  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4643  *
4644  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4645  */
4646 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4647 {
4648 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4649 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4650 #else
4651 	return NULL;
4652 #endif
4653 }
4654 
4655 /**
4656  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4657  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4658  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4659  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4660  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4661  *
4662  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4663  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4664  *
4665  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4666  */
4667 static inline const char *
4668 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4669 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4670 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4671 {
4672 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4673 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4674 						  blink_table_len);
4675 #else
4676 	return NULL;
4677 #endif
4678 }
4679 
4680 /**
4681  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4682  *
4683  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4684  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4685  *
4686  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4687  */
4688 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4689 
4690 /**
4691  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4692  *
4693  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4694  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4695  * before calling this function.
4696  *
4697  * @hw: the hardware to free
4698  */
4699 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4700 
4701 /**
4702  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4703  *
4704  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4705  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4706  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4707  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4708  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4709  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4710  *
4711  * @hw: the hardware to restart
4712  */
4713 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4714 
4715 /**
4716  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4717  *
4718  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4719  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4720  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4721  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4722  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4723  *
4724  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4725  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4726  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4727  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4728  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4729  *
4730  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4731  *
4732  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4733  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4734  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4735  * @list: the destination list
4736  */
4737 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4738 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4739 
4740 /**
4741  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4742  *
4743  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4744  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4745  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4746  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4747  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4748  *
4749  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4750  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4751  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4752  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4753  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4754  *
4755  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4756  *
4757  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4758  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4759  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4760  * @napi: the NAPI context
4761  */
4762 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4763 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4764 
4765 /**
4766  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4767  *
4768  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4769  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4770  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4771  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4772  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4773  *
4774  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4775  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4776  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4777  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4778  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4779  *
4780  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4781  *
4782  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4783  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4784  */
4785 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4786 {
4787 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4788 }
4789 
4790 /**
4791  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4792  *
4793  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4794  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4795  *
4796  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4797  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4798  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4799  *
4800  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4801  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4802  */
4803 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4804 
4805 /**
4806  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4807  *
4808  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4809  * (internally disables bottom halves).
4810  *
4811  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4812  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4813  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4814  *
4815  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4816  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4817  */
4818 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4819 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4820 {
4821 	local_bh_disable();
4822 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4823 	local_bh_enable();
4824 }
4825 
4826 /**
4827  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4828  *
4829  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4830  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4831  * entering/leaving PS mode.
4832  *
4833  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4834  *
4835  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4836  * each other.
4837  *
4838  * @sta: currently connected sta
4839  * @start: start or stop PS
4840  *
4841  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4842  */
4843 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4844 
4845 /**
4846  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4847  *                                  (in process context)
4848  *
4849  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4850  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4851  * applies.
4852  *
4853  * @sta: currently connected sta
4854  * @start: start or stop PS
4855  *
4856  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4857  */
4858 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4859 						  bool start)
4860 {
4861 	int ret;
4862 
4863 	local_bh_disable();
4864 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4865 	local_bh_enable();
4866 
4867 	return ret;
4868 }
4869 
4870 /**
4871  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4872  * @sta: currently connected station
4873  *
4874  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4875  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4876  * connected station was received.
4877  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4878  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4879  * be serialized.
4880  */
4881 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4882 
4883 /**
4884  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4885  * @sta: currently connected station
4886  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4887  *
4888  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4889  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4890  * from a connected station was received.
4891  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4892  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4893  * serialized.
4894  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
4895  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
4896  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
4897  * checks.
4898  */
4899 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
4900 
4901 /*
4902  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
4903  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
4904  */
4905 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
4906 
4907 /**
4908  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
4909  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
4910  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
4911  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
4912  *
4913  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
4914  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
4915  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
4916  *
4917  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
4918  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
4919  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
4920  * call! Beware of the locking!)
4921  *
4922  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
4923  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
4924  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
4925  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
4926  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
4927  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
4928  *
4929  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
4930  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
4931  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
4932  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
4933  * use this API.
4934  */
4935 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4936 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
4937 
4938 /**
4939  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
4940  *
4941  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
4942  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
4943  * rate selection table for the station entry.
4944  *
4945  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4946  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
4947  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
4948  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
4949  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
4950  */
4951 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4952 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4953 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
4954 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
4955 			    int max_rates);
4956 
4957 /**
4958  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
4959  *
4960  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
4961  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
4962  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
4963  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
4964  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
4965  * slow stations to starve).
4966  *
4967  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
4968  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
4969  */
4970 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4971 					   u32 thr);
4972 
4973 /**
4974  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
4975  *
4976  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
4977  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
4978  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
4979  *
4980  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4981  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
4982  * @info: tx status information
4983  */
4984 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4985 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4986 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
4987 
4988 /**
4989  * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
4990  *
4991  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
4992  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
4993  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
4994  *
4995  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4996  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
4997  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
4998  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4999  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5000  *
5001  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5002  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5003  */
5004 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5005 			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5006 
5007 /**
5008  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5009  *
5010  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5011  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5012  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5013  *
5014  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5015  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5016  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5017  *
5018  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5019  * @status: tx status information
5020  */
5021 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5022 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5023 
5024 /**
5025  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5026  *
5027  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5028  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5029  * specific skbs.
5030  *
5031  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5032  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5033  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5034  *
5035  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5036  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5037  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5038  * @info: tx status information
5039  */
5040 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5041 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5042 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5043 {
5044 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5045 		.sta = sta,
5046 		.info = info,
5047 	};
5048 
5049 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5050 }
5051 
5052 /**
5053  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5054  *
5055  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5056  *
5057  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5058  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5059  * for a single hardware.
5060  *
5061  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5062  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5063  */
5064 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5065 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5066 {
5067 	local_bh_disable();
5068 	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5069 	local_bh_enable();
5070 }
5071 
5072 /**
5073  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5074  *
5075  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5076  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5077  *
5078  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5079  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5080  *
5081  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5082  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5083  */
5084 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5085 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5086 
5087 /**
5088  * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format
5089  *
5090  * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit
5091  * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which
5092  * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap
5093  * 802.11 frames.
5094  *
5095  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5096  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all
5097  * calls in the same tx status family.
5098  *
5099  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5100  * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted
5101  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5102  */
5103 void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5104 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5105 			       struct sk_buff *skb);
5106 
5107 /**
5108  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5109  *
5110  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5111  * connected STA.
5112  *
5113  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5114  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5115  */
5116 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5117 
5118 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5119 
5120 /**
5121  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5122  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5123  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5124  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5125  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5126  *	should be ignored.
5127  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5128  */
5129 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5130 	u16 tim_offset;
5131 	u16 tim_length;
5132 
5133 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5134 	u16 mbssid_off;
5135 };
5136 
5137 /**
5138  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5139  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5140  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5141  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5142  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5143  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5144  *
5145  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5146  * obtain the beacon template.
5147  *
5148  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5149  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5150  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5151  * applicable, the CSA count.
5152  *
5153  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5154  *
5155  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5156  */
5157 struct sk_buff *
5158 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5159 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5160 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5161 			      unsigned int link_id);
5162 
5163 /**
5164  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5165  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5166  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5167  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5168  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5169  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5170  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5171  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5172  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5173  *
5174  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5175  * obtain the beacon frame.
5176  *
5177  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5178  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5179  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5180  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5181  *
5182  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5183  *
5184  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5185  */
5186 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5187 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5188 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5189 					 unsigned int link_id);
5190 
5191 /**
5192  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5193  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5194  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5195  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5196  *
5197  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5198  *
5199  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5200  */
5201 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5202 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5203 						   unsigned int link_id)
5204 {
5205 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5206 }
5207 
5208 /**
5209  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5210  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5211  *
5212  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5213  * This function is called implicitly when
5214  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5215  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5216  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5217  *
5218  * Return: new countdown value
5219  */
5220 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5221 
5222 /**
5223  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5224  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5225  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5226  *
5227  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5228  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5229  *
5230  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5231  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5232  */
5233 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5234 
5235 /**
5236  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5237  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5238  *
5239  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5240  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5241  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5242  */
5243 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5244 
5245 /**
5246  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5247  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5248  *
5249  * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5250  */
5251 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5252 
5253 /**
5254  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5255  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5256  *
5257  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5258  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5259  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5260  */
5261 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5262 
5263 /**
5264  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5265  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5266  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5267  *
5268  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5269  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5270  *
5271  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5272  *
5273  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5274  */
5275 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5276 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5277 
5278 /**
5279  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5280  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5281  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5282  *
5283  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5284  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5285  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5286  *
5287  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5288  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5289  *
5290  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5291  */
5292 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5293 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5294 
5295 /**
5296  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5297  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5298  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5299  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5300  *	if at all possible
5301  *
5302  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5303  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5304  * BSSID and address is used.
5305  *
5306  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5307  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5308  *
5309  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5310  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5311  *
5312  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5313  */
5314 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5315 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5316 				       bool qos_ok);
5317 
5318 /**
5319  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5320  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5321  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5322  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5323  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5324  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5325  *
5326  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5327  * hardware.
5328  *
5329  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5330  */
5331 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5332 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5333 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5334 				       size_t tailroom);
5335 
5336 /**
5337  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5338  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5339  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5340  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5341  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5342  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5343  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5344  *
5345  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5346  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5347  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5348  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5349  */
5350 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5351 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5352 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5353 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5354 
5355 /**
5356  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5357  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5358  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5359  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5360  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5361  *
5362  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5363  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5364  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5365  *
5366  * Return: The duration.
5367  */
5368 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5369 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5370 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5371 
5372 /**
5373  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5374  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5375  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5376  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5377  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5378  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5379  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5380  *
5381  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5382  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5383  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5384  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5385  */
5386 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5387 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5388 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5389 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5390 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5391 
5392 /**
5393  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5394  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5395  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5396  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5397  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5398  *
5399  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5400  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5401  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5402  *
5403  * Return: The duration.
5404  */
5405 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5406 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5407 				    size_t frame_len,
5408 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5409 
5410 /**
5411  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5412  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5413  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5414  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5415  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5416  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5417  *
5418  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5419  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5420  *
5421  * Return: The duration.
5422  */
5423 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5424 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5425 					enum nl80211_band band,
5426 					size_t frame_len,
5427 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5428 
5429 /**
5430  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5431  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5432  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5433  *
5434  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5435  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5436  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5437  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5438  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5439  *
5440  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5441  * frames are available.
5442  *
5443  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5444  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5445  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5446  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5447  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5448  * use common code for all beacons.
5449  */
5450 struct sk_buff *
5451 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5452 
5453 /**
5454  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5455  *
5456  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5457  *
5458  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5459  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5460  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5461  */
5462 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5463 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5464 
5465 /**
5466  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5467  *
5468  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5469  * from the given packet.
5470  *
5471  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5472  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5473  *	with this P1K
5474  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5475  */
5476 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5477 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5478 {
5479 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5480 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5481 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5482 
5483 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5484 }
5485 
5486 /**
5487  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5488  *
5489  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5490  * and transmitter address.
5491  *
5492  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5493  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5494  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5495  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5496  */
5497 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5498 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5499 
5500 /**
5501  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5502  *
5503  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5504  * in the packet.
5505  *
5506  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5507  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5508  *	encrypted with this key
5509  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5510  */
5511 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5512 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5513 
5514 /**
5515  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5516  *
5517  * @pos: start of crypto header
5518  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5519  * @pn: PN to add
5520  *
5521  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5522  * the packet payload)
5523  *
5524  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5525  * point to the crypto header)
5526  */
5527 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5528 
5529 /**
5530  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5531  *
5532  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5533  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5534  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5535  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5536  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5537  *
5538  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5539  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5540  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5541  *
5542  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5543  * can be done concurrently.
5544  */
5545 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5546 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5547 
5548 /**
5549  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5550  *
5551  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5552  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5553  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5554  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5555  * @seq: new sequence data
5556  *
5557  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5558  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5559  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5560  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5561  *
5562  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5563  * can be done concurrently.
5564  */
5565 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5566 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5567 
5568 /**
5569  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5570  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5571  *
5572  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5573  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5574  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5575  *
5576  * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5577  * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5578  */
5579 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5580 
5581 /**
5582  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5583  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5584  * @keyconf: new key data
5585  *
5586  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5587  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5588  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5589  *
5590  * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5591  * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5592  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5593  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5594  *
5595  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5596  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5597  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5598  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5599  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5600  * of the reconfiguration.
5601  *
5602  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5603  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5604  *
5605  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5606  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5607  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5608  * the key that's being replaced.
5609  */
5610 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5611 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5612 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5613 
5614 /**
5615  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5616  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5617  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5618  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5619  * @gfp: allocation flags
5620  */
5621 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5622 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5623 
5624 /**
5625  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5626  *
5627  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5628  * at the same time.
5629  *
5630  * @keyconf: the key in question
5631  */
5632 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5633 
5634 /**
5635  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5636  *
5637  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5638  * at the same time.
5639  *
5640  * @keyconf: the key in question
5641  */
5642 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5643 
5644 /**
5645  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5646  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5647  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5648  *
5649  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5650  */
5651 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5652 
5653 /**
5654  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5655  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5656  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5657  *
5658  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5659  */
5660 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5661 
5662 /**
5663  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5664  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5665  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5666  *
5667  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5668  *
5669  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5670  */
5671 
5672 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5673 
5674 /**
5675  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5676  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5677  *
5678  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5679  */
5680 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5681 
5682 /**
5683  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5684  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5685  *
5686  * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5687  */
5688 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5689 
5690 /**
5691  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5692  *
5693  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5694  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5695  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5696  * any context, including hardirq context.
5697  *
5698  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5699  * @info: information about the completed scan
5700  */
5701 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5702 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5703 
5704 /**
5705  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5706  *
5707  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5708  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5709  *
5710  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5711  */
5712 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5713 
5714 /**
5715  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5716  *
5717  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5718  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5719  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5720  * while associating, for instance.
5721  *
5722  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5723  */
5724 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5725 
5726 /**
5727  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5728  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5729  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5730  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5731  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5732  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5733  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5734  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5735  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5736  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5737  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5738  *	for instance.
5739  */
5740 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5741 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5742 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5743 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5744 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5745 };
5746 
5747 /**
5748  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5749  *
5750  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5751  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5752  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5753  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5754  *
5755  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5756  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5757  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5758  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5759  */
5760 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5761 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5762 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5763 				  void *data);
5764 
5765 /**
5766  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5767  *
5768  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5769  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5770  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5771  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5772  * be used.
5773  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5774  *
5775  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5776  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5777  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5778  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5779  */
5780 static inline void
5781 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5782 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5783 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5784 				    void *data)
5785 {
5786 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5787 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5788 				     iterator, data);
5789 }
5790 
5791 /**
5792  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5793  *
5794  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5795  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5796  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5797  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5798  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5799  *
5800  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5801  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5802  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5803  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5804  */
5805 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5806 						u32 iter_flags,
5807 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
5808 						    u8 *mac,
5809 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5810 						void *data);
5811 
5812 /**
5813  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
5814  *
5815  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5816  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5817  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
5818  * The driver must not call this with a lock held that it can also take in
5819  * response to callbacks from mac80211, and it must not call this within
5820  * callbacks made by mac80211 - both would result in deadlocks.
5821  *
5822  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5823  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5824  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5825  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5826  */
5827 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5828 					     u32 iter_flags,
5829 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
5830 						u8 *mac,
5831 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5832 					     void *data);
5833 
5834 /**
5835  * ieee80211_iterate_stations - iterate stations
5836  *
5837  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5838  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5839  * function for them.
5840  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5841  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic can be used.
5842  *
5843  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5844  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5845  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5846  */
5847 void ieee80211_iterate_stations(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5848 				void (*iterator)(void *data,
5849 						 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5850 				void *data);
5851 
5852 /**
5853  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5854  *
5855  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5856  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5857  * function for them.
5858  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5859  *
5860  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5861  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5862  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5863  */
5864 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5865 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
5866 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5867 				       void *data);
5868 /**
5869  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5870  *
5871  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5872  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5873  *
5874  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5875  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5876  */
5877 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5878 
5879 /**
5880  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5881  *
5882  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5883  * workqueue.
5884  *
5885  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5886  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5887  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5888  */
5889 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5890 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
5891 				  unsigned long delay);
5892 
5893 /**
5894  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5895  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5896  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5897  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5898  *
5899  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5900  *
5901  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5902  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5903  * will be managed by the mac80211.
5904  */
5905 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5906 				  u16 timeout);
5907 
5908 /**
5909  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5910  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5911  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5912  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5913  *
5914  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5915  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
5916  * from any context.
5917  */
5918 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5919 				      u16 tid);
5920 
5921 /**
5922  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
5923  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
5924  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
5925  *
5926  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
5927  *
5928  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5929  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5930  * will be managed by the mac80211.
5931  */
5932 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
5933 
5934 /**
5935  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
5936  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5937  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5938  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
5939  *
5940  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5941  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
5942  * can be called from any context.
5943  */
5944 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5945 				     u16 tid);
5946 
5947 /**
5948  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
5949  *
5950  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
5951  * @addr: station's address
5952  *
5953  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5954  *
5955  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5956  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5957  */
5958 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5959 					 const u8 *addr);
5960 
5961 /**
5962  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
5963  *
5964  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5965  * @addr: remote station's address
5966  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
5967  *
5968  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5969  *
5970  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5971  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5972  *
5973  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
5974  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
5975  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
5976  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
5977  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
5978  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
5979  *      is not reliable.
5980  *
5981  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
5982  */
5983 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5984 					       const u8 *addr,
5985 					       const u8 *localaddr);
5986 
5987 /**
5988  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
5989  * @hw: the hardware
5990  * @pubsta: the station
5991  * @block: whether to block or unblock
5992  *
5993  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
5994  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
5995  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
5996  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
5997  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
5998  *
5999  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6000  * manner.
6001  *
6002  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6003  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6004  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6005  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6006  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6007  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6008  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6009  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6010  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6011  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6012  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6013  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6014  * woke up while blocked or not.
6015  */
6016 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6017 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6018 
6019 /**
6020  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6021  * @pubsta: the station
6022  *
6023  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6024  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6025  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6026  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6027  *
6028  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6029  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6030  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6031  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6032  *
6033  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6034  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6035  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6036  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6037  */
6038 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6039 
6040 /**
6041  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6042  * @pubsta: the station
6043  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6044  *
6045  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6046  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6047  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6048  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6049  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6050  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6051  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6052  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6053  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6054  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6055  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6056  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6057  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6058  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6059  */
6060 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6061 
6062 /**
6063  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6064  *
6065  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6066  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6067  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6068  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6069  *
6070  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6071  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6072  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6073  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6074  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6075  * attempts.
6076  *
6077  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6078  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6079  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6080  * them to 0.
6081  *
6082  * @pubsta: the station
6083  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6084  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6085  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6086  */
6087 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6088 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6089 
6090 /**
6091  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6092  *
6093  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6094  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6095  *
6096  * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6097  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6098  */
6099 bool
6100 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6101 
6102 /**
6103  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6104  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6105  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6106  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6107  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6108  *
6109  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6110  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6111  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6112  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6113  * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6114  * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6115  *
6116  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6117  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6118  * set_key callback.
6119  */
6120 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6121 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6122 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6123 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6124 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6125 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6126 				      void *data),
6127 			 void *iter_data);
6128 
6129 /**
6130  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6131  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6132  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6133  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6134  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6135  *
6136  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6137  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6138  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6139  * in removal process will be skipped.
6140  *
6141  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6142  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6143  */
6144 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6145 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6146 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6147 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6148 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6149 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6150 					  void *data),
6151 			     void *iter_data);
6152 
6153 /**
6154  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6155  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6156  * @iter: iterator function
6157  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6158  *
6159  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6160  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6161  * places while calling into the driver.
6162  *
6163  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6164  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6165  * removed.
6166  *
6167  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6168  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6169  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6170  * or not.
6171  */
6172 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6173 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6174 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6175 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6176 		     void *data),
6177 	void *iter_data);
6178 
6179 /**
6180  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6181  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6182  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6183  *
6184  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6185  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6186  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6187  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6188  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6189  * %NULL.
6190  *
6191  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6192  */
6193 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6194 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6195 
6196 /**
6197  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6198  *
6199  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6200  *
6201  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6202  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6203  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6204  */
6205 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6206 
6207 /**
6208  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6209  *
6210  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6211  *
6212  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6213  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6214  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6215  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6216  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6217  *
6218  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6219  * without connection recovery attempts.
6220  */
6221 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6222 
6223 /**
6224  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6225  *
6226  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6227  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6228  *
6229  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6230  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6231  */
6232 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6233 
6234 /**
6235  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6236  *
6237  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6238  *
6239  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6240  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6241  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6242  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6243  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6244  *
6245  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6246  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6247  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6248  * disconnect normally later.
6249  *
6250  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6251  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6252  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6253  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6254  */
6255 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6256 
6257 /**
6258  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6259  * hardware restart
6260  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6261  *
6262  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6263  * hardware restart.
6264  */
6265 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6266 
6267 /**
6268  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6269  *	rssi threshold triggered
6270  *
6271  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6272  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6273  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6274  * @gfp: context flags
6275  *
6276  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6277  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6278  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6279  */
6280 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6281 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6282 			       s32 rssi_level,
6283 			       gfp_t gfp);
6284 
6285 /**
6286  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6287  *
6288  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6289  * @gfp: context flags
6290  */
6291 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6292 
6293 /**
6294  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6295  *
6296  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6297  */
6298 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6299 
6300 /**
6301  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6302  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6303  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6304  *
6305  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6306  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6307  */
6308 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6309 
6310 /**
6311  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6312  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6313  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6314  *
6315  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6316  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6317  * a deauth frame in this case.
6318  */
6319 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6320 					 bool block_tx);
6321 
6322 /**
6323  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6324  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6325  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6326  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6327  *
6328  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6329  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6330  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6331  */
6332 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6333 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6334 
6335 /**
6336  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6337  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6338  */
6339 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6340 
6341 /**
6342  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6343  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6344  */
6345 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6346 
6347 /**
6348  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6349  *
6350  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6351  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6352  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6353  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6354  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6355  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6356  *
6357  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6358  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6359  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6360  */
6361 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6362 				  const u8 *addr);
6363 
6364 /**
6365  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6366  * @pubsta: station struct
6367  * @tid: the session's TID
6368  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6369  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6370  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6371  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6372  *
6373  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6374  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6375  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6376  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6377  */
6378 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6379 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6380 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6381 
6382 /**
6383  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6384  *
6385  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6386  * buffer.
6387  *
6388  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6389  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6390  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6391  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6392  */
6393 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6394 
6395 /**
6396  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6397  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6398  * @addr: station mac address
6399  * @tid: the rx tid
6400  */
6401 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6402 				 unsigned int tid);
6403 
6404 /**
6405  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6406  *
6407  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6408  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6409  * reordering.
6410  *
6411  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6412  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6413  *
6414  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6415  * @addr: station mac address
6416  * @tid: the rx tid
6417  */
6418 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6419 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6420 {
6421 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6422 		return;
6423 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6424 }
6425 
6426 /**
6427  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6428  *
6429  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6430  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6431  * reordering.
6432  *
6433  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6434  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6435  *
6436  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6437  * @addr: station mac address
6438  * @tid: the rx tid
6439  */
6440 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6441 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6442 {
6443 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6444 		return;
6445 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6446 }
6447 
6448 /**
6449  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6450  *
6451  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6452  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6453  *
6454  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6455  *
6456  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6457  * @addr: station mac address
6458  * @tid: the rx tid
6459  */
6460 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6461 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6462 
6463 /* Rate control API */
6464 
6465 /**
6466  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6467  *
6468  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6469  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6470  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6471  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6472  *	to be filled in
6473  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6474  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6475  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6476  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6477  *	RTS threshold
6478  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6479  *	if the selected rate supports it
6480  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6481  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6482  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6483  */
6484 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6485 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6486 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6487 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6488 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6489 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6490 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6491 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6492 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6493 	bool bss;
6494 };
6495 
6496 /**
6497  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6498  */
6499 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6500 	/**
6501 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6502 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6503 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6504 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6505 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6506 	 */
6507 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6508 	/**
6509 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6510 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6511 	 */
6512 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6513 };
6514 
6515 struct rate_control_ops {
6516 	unsigned long capa;
6517 	const char *name;
6518 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6519 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6520 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6521 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6522 
6523 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6524 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6525 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6526 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6527 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6528 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6529 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6530 			    u32 changed);
6531 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6532 			 void *priv_sta);
6533 
6534 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6535 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6536 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6537 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6538 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6539 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6540 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6541 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6542 
6543 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6544 				struct dentry *dir);
6545 
6546 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6547 };
6548 
6549 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6550 				 enum nl80211_band band,
6551 				 int index)
6552 {
6553 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6554 }
6555 
6556 static inline s8
6557 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6558 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6559 {
6560 	int i;
6561 
6562 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6563 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6564 			return i;
6565 
6566 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6567 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6568 
6569 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6570 	return 0;
6571 }
6572 
6573 static inline
6574 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6575 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6576 {
6577 	unsigned int i;
6578 
6579 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6580 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6581 			return true;
6582 	return false;
6583 }
6584 
6585 /**
6586  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6587  *
6588  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6589  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6590  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6591  * the most recent rate control module decision.
6592  *
6593  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6594  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6595  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6596  */
6597 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6598 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6599 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6600 
6601 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6602 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6603 
6604 static inline bool
6605 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6606 {
6607 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6608 }
6609 
6610 static inline bool
6611 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6612 {
6613 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6614 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6615 }
6616 
6617 static inline bool
6618 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6619 {
6620 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6621 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6622 }
6623 
6624 static inline bool
6625 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6626 {
6627 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6628 }
6629 
6630 static inline bool
6631 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6632 {
6633 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6634 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6635 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6636 }
6637 
6638 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6639 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6640 {
6641 	if (p2p) {
6642 		switch (type) {
6643 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6644 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6645 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6646 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6647 		default:
6648 			break;
6649 		}
6650 	}
6651 	return type;
6652 }
6653 
6654 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6655 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6656 {
6657 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6658 }
6659 
6660 /**
6661  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6662  *
6663  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6664  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6665  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6666  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6667  *
6668  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6669  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6670  * matching GroupId management frame.
6671  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6672  */
6673 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6674 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6675 
6676 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6677 				   int rssi_min_thold,
6678 				   int rssi_max_thold);
6679 
6680 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6681 
6682 /**
6683  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6684  *
6685  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6686  *
6687  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6688  *
6689  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6690  * applicable.
6691  */
6692 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6693 
6694 /**
6695  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6696  * @vif: virtual interface
6697  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6698  * @gfp: allocation flags
6699  *
6700  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6701  */
6702 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6703 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6704 				    gfp_t gfp);
6705 
6706 /**
6707  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6708  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6709  * @vif: virtual interface
6710  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6711  * @band: the band to transmit on
6712  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6713  *
6714  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6715  */
6716 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6717 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6718 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6719 
6720 /**
6721  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
6722  *				 of injected frames.
6723  *
6724  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
6725  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
6726  * of the skb before calling this function.
6727  *
6728  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6729  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
6730  */
6731 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6732 				 struct net_device *dev);
6733 
6734 /**
6735  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6736  *
6737  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6738  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6739  *
6740  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6741  *
6742  * private:
6743  *
6744  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6745  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6746  */
6747 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6748 	u32 next_tsf;
6749 	bool has_next_tsf;
6750 
6751 	u8 absent;
6752 
6753 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6754 	struct {
6755 		u32 start;
6756 		u32 duration;
6757 		u32 interval;
6758 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6759 };
6760 
6761 /**
6762  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6763  *
6764  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6765  * @data: NoA tracking data
6766  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6767  *
6768  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6769  */
6770 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6771 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6772 
6773 /**
6774  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6775  *
6776  * @data: NoA tracking data
6777  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6778  */
6779 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6780 
6781 /**
6782  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6783  * @vif: virtual interface
6784  * @peer: the peer's destination address
6785  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6786  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6787  * @gfp: allocation flags
6788  *
6789  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6790  */
6791 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6792 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6793 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6794 
6795 /**
6796  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6797  *
6798  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6799  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6800  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6801  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6802  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6803  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6804  *
6805  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6806  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6807  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6808  *
6809  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6810  * @tid: the TID to reserve
6811  *
6812  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6813  */
6814 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6815 
6816 /**
6817  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6818  *
6819  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6820  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6821  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6822  *
6823  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6824  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6825  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6826  *
6827  * @sta: the station
6828  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6829  */
6830 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6831 
6832 /**
6833  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6834  *
6835  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6836  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6837  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6838  *
6839  * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6840  *
6841  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6842  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6843  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
6844  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6845  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6846  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6847  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6848  *
6849  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6850  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6851  */
6852 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6853 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6854 
6855 /**
6856  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6857  * (in process context)
6858  *
6859  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6860  * (internally disables bottom halves).
6861  *
6862  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6863  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6864  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6865  */
6866 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6867 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6868 {
6869 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6870 
6871 	local_bh_disable();
6872 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6873 	local_bh_enable();
6874 
6875 	return skb;
6876 }
6877 
6878 /**
6879  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
6880  *
6881  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6882  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
6883  *
6884  * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
6885  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
6886  * driver has finished scheduling it.
6887  */
6888 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6889 
6890 /**
6891  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
6892  *
6893  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6894  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
6895  *
6896  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
6897  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
6898  */
6899 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6900 
6901 /* (deprecated) */
6902 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
6903 {
6904 }
6905 
6906 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6907 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
6908 
6909 /**
6910  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
6911  *
6912  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6913  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6914  *
6915  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
6916  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
6917  *
6918  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
6919  * this TXQ internally.
6920  */
6921 static inline void
6922 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6923 {
6924 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
6925 }
6926 
6927 /**
6928  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
6929  *
6930  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6931  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6932  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
6933  *
6934  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
6935  * internally.
6936  */
6937 static inline void
6938 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6939 		     bool force)
6940 {
6941 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
6942 }
6943 
6944 /**
6945  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
6946  *
6947  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
6948  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
6949  * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
6950  * next_txq().
6951  *
6952  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
6953  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
6954  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
6955  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
6956  * again.
6957  *
6958  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
6959  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
6960  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
6961  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
6962  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
6963  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
6964  *
6965  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6966  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6967  */
6968 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6969 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6970 
6971 /**
6972  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
6973  *
6974  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
6975  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
6976  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
6977  *
6978  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6979  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
6980  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
6981  */
6982 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6983 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
6984 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
6985 
6986 /**
6987  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
6988  *
6989  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
6990  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
6991  *
6992  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6993  * @inst_id: the local instance id
6994  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
6995  * @gfp: allocation flags
6996  */
6997 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6998 				   u8 inst_id,
6999 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7000 				   gfp_t gfp);
7001 
7002 /**
7003  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7004  *
7005  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7006  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7007  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7008  *
7009  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7010  * @match: match event information
7011  * @gfp: allocation flags
7012  */
7013 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7014 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7015 			      gfp_t gfp);
7016 
7017 /**
7018  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7019  *
7020  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7021  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7022  *
7023  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7024  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7025  *          information.
7026  * @len: frame length in bytes
7027  */
7028 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7029 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7030 			      int len);
7031 
7032 /**
7033  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7034  *
7035  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7036  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7037  *
7038  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7039  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7040  * @len: frame length in bytes
7041  */
7042 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7043 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7044 			      int len);
7045 /**
7046  * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7047  *
7048  * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7049  * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7050  * hardware or firmware.
7051  *
7052  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7053  * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7054  */
7055 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7056 
7057 /**
7058  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7059  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7060  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7061  *
7062  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7063  *
7064  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7065  */
7066 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7067 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7068 
7069 /**
7070  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7071  *	probe response template.
7072  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7073  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7074  *
7075  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7076  *
7077  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7078  */
7079 struct sk_buff *
7080 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7081 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7082 
7083 /**
7084  * ieeee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7085  * collision.
7086  *
7087  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7088  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7089  *	aware of.
7090  * @gfp: allocation flags
7091  */
7092 void
7093 ieeee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7094 				       u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7095 
7096 /**
7097  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7098  *
7099  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7100  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7101  *
7102  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7103  */
7104 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7105 {
7106 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7107 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7108 
7109 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7110 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7111 }
7112 
7113 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7114